1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2 @c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
5 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
8 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9 @cindex machine description macros
10 @cindex target description macros
11 @cindex macros, target description
12 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
14 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
29 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59 * Misc:: Everything else.
62 @node Target Structure
63 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
65 @cindex target functions
67 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
77 #include "target-def.h"
79 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
81 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
84 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
88 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92 @code{targetm} structure.
95 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
97 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
99 @c prevent bad page break with this line
100 You can control the compilation driver.
102 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
103 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
104 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
106 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
107 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
108 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
109 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
110 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
111 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
113 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
114 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
115 that the other specs are easier to write.
117 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
120 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
121 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
122 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
123 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
124 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
126 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
127 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
128 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
129 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
130 everywhere it occurs.
132 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
133 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
134 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
136 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
140 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
141 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
142 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
144 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
147 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
148 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
149 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
150 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
154 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
155 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
157 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
158 for GCC to pass to front ends.
160 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
164 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
165 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
166 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
168 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
169 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
170 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
171 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
175 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
176 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
177 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
178 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
180 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
183 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
184 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
185 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
186 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
189 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
192 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
193 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
194 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
195 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
196 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
197 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
199 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
200 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
201 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
202 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
206 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
207 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
208 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
210 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
214 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
215 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
216 command given to the linker.
218 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
219 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
223 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
224 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
225 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
226 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
228 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
229 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
232 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
233 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
234 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
235 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
236 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
237 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
238 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
239 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
240 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
241 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
244 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
245 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
246 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
247 generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
248 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
249 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
253 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
254 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
255 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
256 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
259 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
260 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
261 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
262 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
264 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
265 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
269 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
270 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
271 the very end of the command given to the linker.
273 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
276 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
277 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
278 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
279 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
280 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
281 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
282 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
283 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
286 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
287 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
288 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
289 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
292 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
293 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
294 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
295 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
296 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
300 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
301 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
304 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
305 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
306 string constant that provides the specification.
308 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
310 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
311 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
312 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
315 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
316 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
317 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
320 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
323 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
324 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
326 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
329 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
333 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
334 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
335 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
336 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
338 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
339 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
342 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
343 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
346 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
347 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
351 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
352 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
353 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
354 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
357 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
358 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
359 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
362 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
363 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
364 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
365 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
366 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
367 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
368 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
369 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
372 @defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
373 A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
374 directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
375 removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
378 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
379 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
380 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
381 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
382 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
384 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
385 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
386 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
387 @xref{Target Fragment}.
390 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
391 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
392 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
393 indicates an absolute file name.
396 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
397 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
398 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
399 when the compiler is built as a cross
400 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
401 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
404 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
405 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
406 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
407 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
408 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
409 is built as a cross compiler.
412 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
413 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
414 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
415 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
416 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
417 is built as a cross compiler.
420 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
421 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
422 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
423 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
424 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
425 is built as a cross compiler.
428 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
429 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
430 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
431 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
434 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
435 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
436 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
440 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
441 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
442 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
443 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
444 initialize the necessary environment variables.
447 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
448 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
449 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
450 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
451 comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
453 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
457 @defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
458 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
459 system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
460 directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
461 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
463 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
467 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
468 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
469 standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
470 try when searching for header files.
472 Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
473 @file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
476 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
477 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
478 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
479 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
482 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
483 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
484 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
485 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
486 @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
487 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
488 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
489 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
490 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
492 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
493 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
494 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
495 for C++-only directories,
496 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
497 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
498 the array with a null element.
500 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
501 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
502 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
503 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
505 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
508 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
510 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
511 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
512 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
519 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
523 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
526 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
527 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
528 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
531 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
534 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
535 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
538 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
541 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
544 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
548 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
552 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
555 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
556 value based on the installed toolchain location.
559 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
560 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
563 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
564 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
567 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
570 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
574 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
575 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
578 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
579 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
582 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
583 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
584 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
587 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
588 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
592 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
593 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
597 @node Run-time Target
598 @section Run-time Target Specification
599 @cindex run-time target specification
600 @cindex predefined macros
601 @cindex target specifications
603 @c prevent bad page break with this line
604 Here are run-time target specifications.
606 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
607 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
608 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
609 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
610 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
611 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
612 finished command line option processing your code can use those
615 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
616 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
617 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
618 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
620 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
621 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
622 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
623 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
624 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
625 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
626 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
627 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
628 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
629 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
631 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
632 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
633 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
634 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
635 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
636 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
637 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
638 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
642 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
643 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
644 and is used for the target operating system instead.
647 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
648 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
649 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
650 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
654 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
655 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
656 any target-specific headers.
659 @hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
660 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
661 Its default setting is 0.
664 @cindex optional hardware or system features
665 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
667 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
668 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
669 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
670 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
671 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
672 definition does nothing but return true.
674 @var{code} specifies the @code{OPT_@var{name}} enumeration value
675 associated with the selected option; @var{name} is just a rendering of
676 the option name in which non-alphanumeric characters are replaced by
677 underscores. @var{arg} specifies the string argument and is null if
678 no argument was given. If the option is flagged as a @code{UInteger}
679 (@pxref{Option properties}), @var{value} is the numeric value of the
680 argument. Otherwise @var{value} is 1 if the positive form of the
681 option was used and 0 if the ``no-'' form was.
684 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
685 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
686 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
687 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
688 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
689 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
690 default definition does nothing but return false.
692 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
693 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
694 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
695 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
698 @hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
700 @hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
702 @hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
704 @defmac TARGET_VERSION
705 This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
706 describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
707 description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
711 #define TARGET_VERSION \
712 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
714 #define TARGET_VERSION \
715 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
720 @hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
721 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
722 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
723 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
724 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
725 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
726 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
727 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
730 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
731 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
732 but is only used in the C
733 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
734 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
738 @hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
739 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
740 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
741 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
742 options are processed once
743 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
744 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
745 options passed explicily.
747 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
748 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
749 @code{optimize} attribute.
752 @hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
754 @hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
757 This hook is called in response to the user invoking
758 @option{--target-help} on the command line. It gives the target a
759 chance to display extra information on the target specific command
760 line options found in its @file{.opt} file.
763 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
764 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
765 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
766 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
767 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
768 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
770 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
771 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
772 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
773 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
774 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
775 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
776 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
778 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
782 @node Per-Function Data
783 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
784 @cindex per-function data
785 @cindex data structures
787 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
788 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
789 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
790 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
791 when another one comes along.
793 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
794 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
795 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
796 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
797 to their own specific data.
799 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
800 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
801 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
802 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
804 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
805 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
806 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
807 function, for level 0.
809 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
810 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
811 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
812 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
813 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
814 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
815 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
816 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
819 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
820 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
821 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
822 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
823 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
826 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
827 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
828 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
829 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
830 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
831 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
833 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
834 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
835 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
839 @section Storage Layout
840 @cindex storage layout
842 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
843 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
844 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
845 @xref{Run-time Target}.
847 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
848 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
849 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
850 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
851 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
852 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
853 macro need not be a constant.
855 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
856 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
859 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
860 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
861 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
864 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
865 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
866 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
867 memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
868 order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
869 macro need not be a constant.
872 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
873 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
874 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
875 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
876 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
878 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
882 @defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
883 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
884 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
887 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
888 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
889 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
892 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
893 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
894 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
895 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
898 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
899 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
900 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
903 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
904 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
905 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
906 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
910 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
911 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
912 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
913 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
916 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
917 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
918 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
919 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
920 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
921 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
922 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
924 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
925 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
928 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
929 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
930 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
931 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
934 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
935 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
936 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
937 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
938 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
941 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
942 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
943 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
944 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
945 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
946 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
948 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
951 @hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
952 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
953 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
954 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
955 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
958 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
959 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
960 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
961 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
962 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
963 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
964 the signedness may be different.
966 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
967 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
968 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
971 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
972 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
973 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
974 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
978 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
979 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
980 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
981 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
982 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
983 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
986 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
987 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
988 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
989 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
990 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
991 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
994 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
995 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
996 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
997 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1000 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1001 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1004 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1005 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1006 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1007 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1010 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1011 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1012 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1015 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1016 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1017 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1020 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1021 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1022 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1023 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1024 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1027 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1028 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1029 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1030 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1031 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1034 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1035 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1036 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1037 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1038 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1039 field alignment has not been set by the
1040 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1043 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1044 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1045 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1047 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1049 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1050 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1051 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1052 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1055 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1056 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1057 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1058 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1059 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1061 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1062 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1063 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1064 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1065 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1068 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1069 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1070 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1071 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1072 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1074 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1077 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1078 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1079 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1080 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1083 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1084 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1085 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1086 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1087 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1090 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1092 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1093 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1094 constants can be done inline.
1097 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1098 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1099 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1100 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1101 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1103 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1105 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1106 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1109 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1110 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1111 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1112 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1113 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1116 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1117 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1120 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1121 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1124 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1125 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1126 variable @var{decl}.
1128 If this macro is not defined, then
1129 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1132 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1133 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1136 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1137 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1138 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1139 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1141 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1144 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1145 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1146 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1148 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1151 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1152 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1153 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1155 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1156 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1159 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1160 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1161 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1162 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1165 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1166 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1167 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1169 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1170 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1171 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1172 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1173 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1175 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1176 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1177 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1178 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1180 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1183 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1184 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1186 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1187 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1188 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1189 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1191 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1192 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1193 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1195 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1196 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1197 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1199 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1200 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1201 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1220 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1221 sizeof (struct foo1));
1222 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1223 sizeof (struct foo2));
1228 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1229 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1232 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1233 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1234 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1237 @hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1238 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1239 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1240 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1241 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1244 @hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1245 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1246 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1247 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1249 The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1252 @defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1253 Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1256 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1257 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1258 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1259 retain the field's mode.
1261 Normally, this is not needed.
1264 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1265 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1266 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1267 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1270 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1271 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1274 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1275 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1276 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1277 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1278 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1279 (DImode)} is assumed.
1282 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1283 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1284 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1285 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1286 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1287 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1288 having its mode specified.
1290 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1291 would most commonly define this macro if the
1292 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1296 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1297 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1298 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1299 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1301 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1302 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1303 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1306 @hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1307 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1308 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1309 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1313 @hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1314 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1315 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1316 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1320 @hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1321 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1322 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1325 @defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1326 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1327 mode is towards zero.
1329 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1330 floating-point arithmetic.
1332 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1335 @defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1336 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1337 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1338 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1340 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1341 floating-point arithmetic.
1343 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1346 @hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1347 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1348 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1349 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1350 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1351 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1352 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1353 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1354 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1355 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1356 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1357 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1359 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1360 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1361 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1362 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1363 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1364 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1365 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1367 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1368 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1369 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1370 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1371 may affect its placement.
1374 @hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1375 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1378 @hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1379 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1382 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1383 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1384 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1385 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1386 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1387 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1391 @hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1392 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1393 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1396 @hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1397 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1398 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1399 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1400 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1401 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1402 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1403 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1404 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1407 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1408 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1409 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1410 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1411 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1412 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1413 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1414 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1415 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1416 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1417 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1418 spaces in your string.
1420 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1421 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1422 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1425 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1426 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1431 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1433 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1434 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1435 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1436 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1438 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1439 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1440 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1443 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1444 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1445 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1446 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1450 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1451 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1452 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1455 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1456 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1457 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1458 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1459 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1460 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1463 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1464 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1465 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1466 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1467 macro must be at least 64.
1470 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1471 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1472 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1473 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1476 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1477 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1478 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1479 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1482 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1483 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1484 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1487 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1488 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1489 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1493 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1494 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1495 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1499 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1500 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1501 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1502 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1505 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1506 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1507 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1508 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1511 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1512 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1513 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1514 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1517 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1518 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1519 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1520 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1523 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1524 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1525 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1526 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1529 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1530 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1531 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1532 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1535 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1536 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1537 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1538 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1541 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1542 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1543 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1544 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1547 @defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1548 Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1549 if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1550 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1551 default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1554 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1555 Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1556 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1557 @code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1558 anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1559 or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1563 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1564 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1565 @code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1566 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1567 is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1570 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1571 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1572 @code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1573 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1574 is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1581 Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1582 @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1583 if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1584 @code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1585 for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1586 @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1587 @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1588 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1591 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1592 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1593 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1594 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1595 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1598 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1599 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1600 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1601 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1602 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1606 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1607 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1608 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1609 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1610 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1613 @hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1614 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1615 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1616 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1617 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1619 The default is to return false.
1623 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1624 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1625 contents of the string.
1627 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1628 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1629 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1630 of the data type names defined in the function
1631 @code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1632 omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1635 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1639 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1640 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1641 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1642 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1643 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1645 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1649 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1650 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1651 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1654 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1657 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1658 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1659 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1664 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1665 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1666 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1667 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1670 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1674 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1675 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1676 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1677 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1679 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1680 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1681 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1684 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1685 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1686 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1687 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1688 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1690 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1691 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1692 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1696 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1702 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1703 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1704 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1705 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1706 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1707 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1708 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1709 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1710 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1711 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1712 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1713 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1714 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1715 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1716 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1717 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1718 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1719 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1720 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1721 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1722 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1723 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1724 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1725 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1726 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1727 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1728 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1729 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1730 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1731 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1732 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1734 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1735 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1736 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1737 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1738 these macros are null pointers.
1741 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1742 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1749 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1756 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1757 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1758 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1759 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1760 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1761 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1762 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1763 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1765 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1766 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1767 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1768 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1769 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1770 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1771 architecture, you should define this macro to
1772 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1774 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1775 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1776 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1777 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1780 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1781 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1782 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1783 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1784 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1785 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1786 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1788 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1789 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1792 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1793 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1794 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1795 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1796 when special alignment is necessary. */
1799 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1800 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1801 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1802 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1803 of words in each data entry.
1807 @section Register Usage
1808 @cindex register usage
1810 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1811 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1813 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1814 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1815 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1816 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1817 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1820 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1821 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1822 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1823 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1824 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1827 @node Register Basics
1828 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1830 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1831 Registers have various characteristics.
1833 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1834 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1835 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1836 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1837 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1840 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1841 @cindex fixed register
1842 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1843 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1844 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1845 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1846 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1847 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1848 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1850 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1851 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1852 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1854 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1855 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1856 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1857 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1858 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1861 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1862 @cindex call-used register
1863 @cindex call-clobbered register
1864 @cindex call-saved register
1865 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1866 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1867 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1868 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1871 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1872 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1873 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1876 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1877 @cindex call-used register
1878 @cindex call-clobbered register
1879 @cindex call-saved register
1880 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1881 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1882 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1883 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1884 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1887 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1888 @cindex call-used register
1889 @cindex call-clobbered register
1890 @cindex call-saved register
1891 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1892 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1893 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1894 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1895 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1899 @findex call_used_regs
1902 @findex reg_class_contents
1903 @defmac CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1904 Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1905 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1906 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1907 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1908 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1909 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1910 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1911 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1912 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1913 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1914 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1915 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1916 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1917 command options have been applied.
1919 You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1921 @cindex disabling certain registers
1922 @cindex controlling register usage
1923 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1924 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1925 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1926 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1927 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1928 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1929 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1931 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1932 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1933 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1934 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1937 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1938 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1939 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1940 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1941 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1945 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1946 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1947 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1948 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1949 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1953 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1954 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1955 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1956 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1957 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1962 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1963 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1966 @node Allocation Order
1967 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1968 @cindex order of register allocation
1969 @cindex register allocation order
1971 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1972 Registers are allocated in order.
1974 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1975 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1976 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1977 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1979 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1980 (all else being equal).
1982 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1983 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1984 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1985 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1986 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1989 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1990 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1991 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1993 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1994 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1995 register; and so on.
1997 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1998 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2000 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2003 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2004 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2005 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2006 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2007 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2008 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2012 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2013 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2014 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2015 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2016 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2017 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2018 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2019 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2021 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2024 @node Values in Registers
2025 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2027 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2028 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2029 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2031 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2032 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2033 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2034 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2035 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2036 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2038 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2039 definition of this macro is
2042 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2043 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2048 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2049 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2050 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2051 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2052 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2053 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2054 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2056 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2057 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2060 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2061 @code{subreg_get_info}
2062 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2063 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2064 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2065 registers and so not be representable.
2068 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2069 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2070 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2071 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2072 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2075 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2076 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2077 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2078 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2079 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2080 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2081 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2084 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2085 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2086 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2087 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2088 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2091 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2094 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2095 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2097 @cindex register pairs
2098 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2099 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2100 odd register numbers for such modes.
2102 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2103 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2104 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2105 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2107 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2108 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2109 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2110 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2111 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2112 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2115 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2116 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2117 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2118 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2119 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2120 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2122 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2123 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2124 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2125 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2126 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2127 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2128 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2129 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2130 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2132 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2133 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2134 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2135 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2136 constraints for those instructions.
2138 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2139 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2140 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2141 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2142 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2145 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2146 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2147 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2149 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2150 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2153 The default is always nonzero.
2156 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2157 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2158 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2160 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2161 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2162 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2163 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2164 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2165 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2167 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2168 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2172 @hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2173 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2174 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2176 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2177 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2179 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2182 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2183 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2184 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2185 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2188 @node Leaf Functions
2189 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2191 @cindex leaf functions
2192 @cindex functions, leaf
2193 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2194 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2195 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2196 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2199 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2200 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2201 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2202 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2203 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2206 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2207 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2208 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2211 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2212 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2213 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2216 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2217 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2218 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2219 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2222 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2223 the treatment of leaf functions.
2226 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2227 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2228 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2230 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2231 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2232 will cause the compiler to abort.
2234 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2235 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2239 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2240 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2241 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2242 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2243 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2244 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2245 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2246 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2247 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2248 functions which only use leaf registers.
2249 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2250 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2251 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2252 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2253 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2255 @node Stack Registers
2256 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2258 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2259 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2260 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2263 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2264 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2265 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2266 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2267 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2268 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2269 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2272 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2275 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2276 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2277 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2280 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2281 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2285 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2286 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2290 @node Register Classes
2291 @section Register Classes
2292 @cindex register class definitions
2293 @cindex class definitions, register
2295 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2296 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2297 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2298 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2300 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2301 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2302 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2306 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2307 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2308 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2309 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2311 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2312 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2313 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2314 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2315 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2318 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2319 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2321 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2322 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2323 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2324 them in operand constraints.
2326 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2327 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2328 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2329 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2330 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2332 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2333 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2334 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2337 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2338 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2339 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2340 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2341 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2343 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2344 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2345 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2346 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2347 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2348 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2349 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2350 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2351 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2353 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2354 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2355 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2356 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2357 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2358 tells how many classes there are.
2360 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2361 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2362 in many of the tables described below.
2365 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2366 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2369 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2373 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2374 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2375 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2378 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2379 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2380 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2381 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2382 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2384 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2385 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2386 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2387 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2388 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2389 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2393 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2394 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2395 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2396 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2400 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2401 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2402 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2403 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2406 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2407 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2408 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2409 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2410 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2413 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2414 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2415 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2416 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2417 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2420 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2421 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2422 base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2423 context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2424 the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2425 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2426 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2427 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2430 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2431 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2432 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2433 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2434 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2437 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2438 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2439 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2442 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2443 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2444 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2445 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2446 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2447 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2448 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2449 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2450 @code{address_operand}.
2453 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2454 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2455 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2456 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2457 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2458 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2459 than other base register uses.
2461 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2462 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2465 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2466 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2467 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2468 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2469 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2470 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2471 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2472 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2473 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2474 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2477 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2478 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2479 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2480 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2481 allocated such a hard register.
2483 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2484 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2485 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2486 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2487 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2488 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2489 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2490 only if neither labeling works.
2493 @hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2494 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2495 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2496 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2497 another, smaller class.
2499 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2501 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2502 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2503 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2504 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2505 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2507 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2508 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2509 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2510 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2511 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2512 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2513 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2514 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2515 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2516 @code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2517 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2519 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2520 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2521 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2522 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2523 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2524 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2527 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2528 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2529 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2530 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2531 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2535 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2538 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2539 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2540 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2541 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2542 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2544 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2545 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2546 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2547 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2548 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2549 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2550 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2551 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2552 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2553 @code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2554 of using @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2556 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2557 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2558 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2559 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2560 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2561 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2564 @defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2565 Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2566 input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2567 @var{class}, unchanged.
2569 You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2570 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2573 @hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2574 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2577 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2580 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2581 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2584 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2585 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2586 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2587 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2590 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2591 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2593 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2596 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2597 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2600 @hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2601 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2602 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2603 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2604 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2605 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2606 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2607 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2608 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2609 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2610 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2611 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2612 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2614 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2615 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2616 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2617 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2618 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2619 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2620 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2621 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2622 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2623 of the scratch register(s).
2625 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2627 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2628 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2629 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2630 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2631 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2633 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2634 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2635 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2636 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2637 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2638 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2640 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2641 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2642 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2643 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2644 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2646 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2647 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2648 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2649 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2650 single-register-class
2651 @c [later: or memory]
2654 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2655 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2656 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2657 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2659 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2660 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2661 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2662 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2663 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2664 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2665 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2666 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2669 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2670 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2671 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2672 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2674 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2675 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2676 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2678 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2679 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2680 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2681 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2682 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2683 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2686 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2687 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2688 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2689 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2690 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2692 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2693 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2694 reload phase that it may
2695 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2696 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2697 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2698 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2699 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2700 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2702 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2703 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2704 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2705 class required. If the
2706 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2707 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2710 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2711 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2712 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2713 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2714 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2716 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2717 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2718 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2719 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2720 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2721 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2724 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2726 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2727 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2728 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2729 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2730 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2732 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2733 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2734 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2735 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2737 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2738 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2739 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2740 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2741 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2742 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2746 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2747 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2748 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2749 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2750 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2751 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2752 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2754 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2757 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2758 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2759 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2760 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2761 defined by this macro.
2763 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2764 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2767 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2768 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2769 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2770 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2771 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2772 same as that of @var{mode}.
2774 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2775 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2776 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2779 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2780 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2781 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2782 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2783 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2786 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2787 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2788 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2791 @hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2792 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2793 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2794 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2796 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2797 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2798 default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2799 if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2800 hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2801 @code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2802 @file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2803 register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2804 you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2805 the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2809 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2810 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2811 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2813 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2814 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2815 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2816 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2818 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2822 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2823 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2824 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2826 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2827 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2828 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2829 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2830 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2834 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2835 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2836 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2840 @hook TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2841 Return an array of cover classes for the Integrated Register Allocator
2842 (@acronym{IRA}). Cover classes are a set of non-intersecting register
2843 classes covering all hard registers used for register allocation
2844 purposes. If a move between two registers in the same cover class is
2845 possible, it should be cheaper than a load or store of the registers.
2846 The array is terminated by a @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES} element.
2848 The order of cover classes in the array is important. If two classes
2849 have the same cost of usage for a pseudo, the class occurred first in
2850 the array is chosen for the pseudo.
2852 This hook is called once at compiler startup, after the command-line
2853 options have been processed. It is then re-examined by every call to
2854 @code{target_reinit}.
2856 The default implementation returns @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES}, if defined,
2857 otherwise there is no default implementation. You must define either this
2858 macro or @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES} in order to use the integrated register
2859 allocator with Chaitin-Briggs coloring. If the macro is not defined,
2860 the only available coloring algorithm is Chow's priority coloring.
2863 @defmac IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2864 See the documentation for @code{TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES}.
2867 @node Old Constraints
2868 @section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2869 @cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2870 @cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2872 Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2873 of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2874 Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2875 it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2877 @defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2878 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2879 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2880 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2881 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2882 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2883 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2884 to handle specially.
2885 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2886 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2887 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2888 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2889 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2892 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2893 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2894 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2895 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2896 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2897 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2898 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2901 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2902 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2903 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2907 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2908 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2909 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2910 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2911 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2912 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2913 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2917 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2918 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2919 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2920 between different variants.
2923 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2924 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2925 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2926 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2928 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2929 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2930 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2931 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2933 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2934 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2935 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2936 between these kinds.
2939 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2940 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2941 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2942 between different variants.
2945 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2946 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2947 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2948 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2949 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2950 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2951 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2953 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2954 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2955 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2956 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2958 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2959 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2960 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2961 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2962 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2963 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2964 does not include r0 on the output.
2967 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2968 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2969 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2973 @defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2974 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2975 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2976 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2978 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2979 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2980 comprises a subset of all memory references including
2981 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2982 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2983 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2985 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2986 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2987 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2988 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2989 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2990 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2991 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2992 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2993 an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2996 @defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2997 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2998 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2999 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3000 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3002 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3003 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3004 a subset of all memory addresses including
3005 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3006 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3007 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3009 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3010 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3011 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3014 @node Stack and Calling
3015 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3016 @cindex calling conventions
3018 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3019 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3023 * Exception Handling::
3028 * Register Arguments::
3030 * Aggregate Return::
3035 * Stack Smashing Protection::
3039 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3040 @cindex stack frame layout
3041 @cindex frame layout
3043 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3044 Here is the basic stack layout.
3046 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3047 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3048 pointer to a smaller address.
3050 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3051 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3052 definition used does not matter.
3055 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3056 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3057 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3058 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3060 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3061 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3062 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3063 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3064 space for the next item on the stack.
3066 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3067 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3068 which is often wrong.
3071 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3072 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3073 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3076 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3077 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3078 addresses on the stack.
3081 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3082 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3084 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3085 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3086 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3087 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3088 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3089 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3092 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3093 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3094 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3096 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3097 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3098 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3099 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3102 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3103 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3104 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3105 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3107 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3108 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3111 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3112 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3113 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3116 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3117 the first argument's address.
3120 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3121 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3122 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3124 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3125 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3126 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3129 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3130 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3131 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3132 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3133 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3134 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3135 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3138 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3139 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3140 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3141 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3144 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3145 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3146 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3149 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3150 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3151 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3152 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3153 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3157 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3158 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3159 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3160 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3161 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3162 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3165 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3166 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3167 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3168 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3169 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3170 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3173 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3174 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3175 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3176 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3177 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3178 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3180 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3181 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3182 determine the return address of other frames.
3185 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3186 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3187 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3190 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3191 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3192 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3193 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3194 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3197 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3198 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3200 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3201 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3204 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3205 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3206 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3207 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3208 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3210 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3211 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3212 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3216 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3217 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3218 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3219 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3220 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3221 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3224 @hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3225 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3226 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3227 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3229 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3233 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3235 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3236 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3237 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3240 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3241 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3242 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3243 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3244 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3245 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3247 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3248 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3251 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3252 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3253 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3254 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3255 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3256 during virtual register instantiation.
3258 The default value for this macro is
3259 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3260 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3261 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3262 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3263 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3265 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3266 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3270 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3271 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3272 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3273 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3274 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3276 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3277 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3278 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3279 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3280 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3281 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3285 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3286 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3287 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3288 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3289 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3292 @node Exception Handling
3293 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3294 @cindex exception handling
3296 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3297 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3298 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3299 @var{N} registers are usable.
3301 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3302 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3303 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3304 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3305 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3307 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3308 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3311 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3312 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3313 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3314 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3315 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3317 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3318 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3320 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3321 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3322 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3323 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3324 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3325 that provided by DWARF 2.
3328 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3329 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3330 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3331 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3333 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3334 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3335 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3336 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3337 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3338 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3341 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3342 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3343 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3345 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3346 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3349 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3350 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3351 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3352 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3353 using it to return to the exception handler.
3356 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3357 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3358 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3359 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3360 and so may be read-only.
3362 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3363 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3364 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3365 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3367 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3368 represented directly.
3371 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3372 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3373 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3374 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3375 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3377 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3378 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3379 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3383 @defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
3384 A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c. The file
3385 so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
3388 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3389 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3390 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3391 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3392 through signal frames.
3394 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3395 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3396 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3397 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3398 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3399 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3400 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3401 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3402 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3404 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3405 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3408 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3409 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3410 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3411 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3413 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3414 @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3415 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3416 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3417 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3418 be updated in @var{fs}.
3421 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3422 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3423 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3424 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3427 @node Stack Checking
3428 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3430 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3431 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3436 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3437 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3438 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3439 other special processing.
3442 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3443 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3444 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3445 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3446 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3447 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3451 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3452 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3455 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3456 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3457 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3458 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3460 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3461 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3462 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3463 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3464 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3465 value of this macro is zero.
3468 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3469 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3470 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3471 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3472 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3475 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3476 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3477 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3478 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3479 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3480 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3483 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3484 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3485 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3486 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3487 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3488 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3489 default value of this macro is zero.
3492 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3493 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3494 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3495 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3496 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3500 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3501 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3502 in the opposite case.
3504 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3505 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3506 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3507 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3508 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3509 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3510 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3513 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3514 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3515 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3516 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3517 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3518 use the default of four words.
3521 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3522 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3523 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3524 @option{-fstack-check}.
3525 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3526 normally not need to override that default.
3530 @node Frame Registers
3531 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3533 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3534 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3536 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3537 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3538 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3539 the hardware determines which register this is.
3542 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3543 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3544 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3545 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3546 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3549 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3550 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3551 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3552 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3553 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3554 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3555 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3556 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3557 used for the frame pointer.
3559 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3560 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3561 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3562 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3563 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3564 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3565 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3567 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3568 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3571 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3572 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3573 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3574 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3575 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3576 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3577 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3578 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3579 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3582 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3583 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3584 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3585 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3586 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3587 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3590 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3591 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3592 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3593 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3594 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3595 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3598 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3599 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3600 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3601 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3602 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3603 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3604 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3606 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3607 address from the stack.
3610 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3611 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3612 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3613 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3614 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3615 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3616 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3619 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3621 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3622 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3625 @hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3626 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3627 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3628 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3629 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3630 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3632 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3634 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3635 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3636 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3637 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3638 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3639 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3640 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3641 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3642 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3643 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3644 to refer to those items.
3647 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3648 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3649 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3650 DWARF2 exception handling.
3652 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3653 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3654 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3655 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3656 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3657 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3658 registers that are not call-saved.
3660 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3661 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3664 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3666 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3667 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3669 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3670 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3673 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3675 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3676 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3677 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3678 column number to use instead.
3680 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3683 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3685 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3686 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3687 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3688 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3689 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3693 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3695 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3696 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3697 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3698 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3699 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3704 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3706 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3707 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3709 @hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3710 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3711 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3712 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3714 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3715 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3716 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3717 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3718 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3721 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3722 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3723 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3724 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3727 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3728 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3729 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3731 Default return value is @code{false}.
3734 @findex get_frame_size
3735 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3736 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3737 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3738 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3739 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3740 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3742 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3743 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3744 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3745 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3748 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3749 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3750 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3751 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3752 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3754 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3755 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3757 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3758 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3759 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3760 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3761 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3763 In this case, you might specify:
3765 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3766 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3767 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3768 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3771 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3772 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3775 @hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3776 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3777 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3778 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3779 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3780 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3783 Default return value is @code{true}.
3786 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3787 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3788 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3789 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3793 @node Stack Arguments
3794 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3795 @cindex arguments on stack
3796 @cindex stack arguments
3798 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3799 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3800 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3802 @hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3803 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3804 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3805 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3806 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3807 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3811 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3813 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3814 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3815 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3816 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3819 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3820 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3821 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3822 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3823 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3826 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3827 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3828 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3830 On some machines, the definition
3833 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3837 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3838 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3839 alignment. Then the definition should be
3842 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3846 @findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3847 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3848 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3849 will be computed and placed into the variable
3850 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3851 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3852 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3854 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3858 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3859 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3860 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3863 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3864 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3865 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3866 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3869 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3870 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3873 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3874 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3876 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3877 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3878 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3879 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3880 if the function called is a library function.
3882 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3883 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3884 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3887 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3888 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3889 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3890 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3891 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3893 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3894 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3895 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3896 stack in its natural location.
3899 @hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
3900 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3901 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3902 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3904 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3905 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3906 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3907 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3909 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3910 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3911 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3912 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3913 arguments (if known).
3915 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3916 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3917 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3918 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3919 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3920 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3922 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3923 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3924 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3926 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3927 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3928 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3929 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3930 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3931 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3932 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3933 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3934 number of arguments.
3937 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3938 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3939 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3940 when compiling a function call.
3942 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3943 have been accumulated.
3945 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3946 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3947 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3948 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3952 @node Register Arguments
3953 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3954 @cindex arguments in registers
3955 @cindex registers arguments
3957 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3958 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3961 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3962 A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3963 in a register, and which register.
3965 The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
3966 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3967 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3968 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3969 which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
3970 correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
3971 @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
3974 The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
3975 hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
3976 argument on the stack.
3978 For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
3979 pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
3981 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3982 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3983 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3984 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3985 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3986 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3987 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3988 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3989 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3990 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3991 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3992 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3993 argument is also stored on the stack.
3995 The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3996 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3997 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3999 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4000 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
4001 where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
4002 nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
4003 by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
4005 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4006 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4007 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4008 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4009 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4010 is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4011 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4012 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4016 @hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4017 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4018 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4019 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4023 @defmac FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4024 Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4025 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4026 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4029 For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
4030 the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
4031 be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
4032 where the arguments will arrive.
4034 If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4035 serves both purposes.
4038 @hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4039 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4040 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4041 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4042 pushed on the stack.
4044 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4045 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4046 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4047 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4048 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4049 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4050 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4052 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4053 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4054 @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4057 @hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
4058 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4059 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4060 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4061 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4063 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4064 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4065 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4069 @hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4070 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4071 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4072 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4075 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4076 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4079 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4082 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4083 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
4084 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
4085 the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
4088 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4089 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4090 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4091 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4092 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4093 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4096 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4097 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4098 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4099 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4100 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4101 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4102 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4105 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4106 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4107 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4108 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4109 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4110 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4111 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4112 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4113 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4114 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4115 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4116 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4117 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4119 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4120 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4121 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4122 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4123 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4124 never both of them at once.
4127 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4128 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4129 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4130 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4131 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4132 0)} is used instead.
4135 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4136 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4137 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4138 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4140 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4141 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4142 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4143 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4144 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4145 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4148 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4149 A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
4150 @var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
4151 values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
4152 Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
4153 the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4155 This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4156 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4157 used for arguments without any special help.
4160 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4161 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4162 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4163 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4164 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4168 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4169 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4170 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4171 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4172 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4174 The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
4175 multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
4178 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4179 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4180 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4181 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4184 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4185 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4186 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4187 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4188 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4189 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4192 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4193 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4194 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4195 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4196 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4197 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4198 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4199 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4203 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4204 If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
4205 of an argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
4206 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
4209 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4210 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4211 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4212 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4213 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4214 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4218 @hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4219 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4220 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4221 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4222 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4223 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4224 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4227 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4231 @hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4232 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4233 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4236 @hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
4237 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4238 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4239 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4240 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4242 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4243 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4245 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4246 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4247 macro to iterate through all types.
4250 @hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4251 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4253 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4256 @hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4257 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4258 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4262 @hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4263 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4264 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4265 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4266 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4269 @hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4270 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4271 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4272 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4275 @hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4276 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4277 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4278 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4281 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4282 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4283 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4284 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4287 @hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4288 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4289 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4290 must have move patterns for this mode.
4293 @hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4294 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4295 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4296 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4297 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4298 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4301 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4302 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4303 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4304 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4307 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4308 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4309 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4310 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4311 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4312 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4313 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4314 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4315 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4317 The default version of this hook retuns false for any mode. It is always
4318 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4319 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4320 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4321 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4322 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4326 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4327 @cindex return values in registers
4328 @cindex values, returned by functions
4329 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4331 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4332 values---values that can fit in registers.
4334 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4336 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4337 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4338 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4339 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4340 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4341 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4342 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4343 a function returns a value.
4345 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4346 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4347 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4348 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4349 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4350 multiple places. See @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4351 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4352 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4353 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4354 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4355 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4356 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4358 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4359 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4360 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4362 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4363 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4364 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4365 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4368 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4369 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4370 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4371 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4373 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4374 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4375 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4378 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4379 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4380 a new target instead.
4383 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4384 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4385 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4387 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4388 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4389 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4393 @hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4394 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4395 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4397 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4398 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4399 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4401 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4404 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4405 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4406 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4408 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4409 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4410 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4414 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4417 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4418 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4419 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4421 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4422 for a new target instead.
4425 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4426 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4427 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4429 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4430 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4431 recognized by this target hook.
4433 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4434 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4435 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4437 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4440 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4441 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4442 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4443 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4446 @hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4447 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4448 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4449 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4450 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4452 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4453 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4454 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4455 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4459 @node Aggregate Return
4460 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4461 @cindex aggregates as return values
4462 @cindex large return values
4463 @cindex returning aggregate values
4464 @cindex structure value address
4466 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4467 cases), the value is not returned according to
4468 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4469 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4470 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4473 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4476 @hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4477 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4478 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4479 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4480 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4483 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4484 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4485 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4486 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4487 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4488 values, and 0 otherwise.
4490 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4491 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4495 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4496 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4497 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4498 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4499 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4500 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4503 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4506 @hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4507 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4508 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4509 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4510 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4511 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4514 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4515 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4516 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4517 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4518 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4519 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4522 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4523 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4524 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4525 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4526 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4529 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4530 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4531 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4532 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4534 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4535 pass an address to the subroutine.
4537 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4538 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4541 @hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4543 @hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4546 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4548 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4549 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4550 must live across calls.
4552 @defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4553 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4554 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4555 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4556 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4558 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4559 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4562 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4563 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4564 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4565 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4566 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4567 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4570 @node Function Entry
4571 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4572 @cindex function entry and exit
4576 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4577 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4579 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4580 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4581 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4582 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4583 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4584 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4585 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4587 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4588 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4590 @findex regs_ever_live
4591 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4592 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4593 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4594 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4595 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4596 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4598 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4599 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4600 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4601 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4602 registers are used in the function.
4604 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4605 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4606 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4607 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4608 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4609 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4610 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4612 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4613 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4614 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4615 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4616 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4617 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4618 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4619 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4620 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4621 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4624 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4625 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4626 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4627 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4628 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4631 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4632 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4633 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4634 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4635 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4638 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4639 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4640 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4641 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4642 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4643 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4644 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4645 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4647 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4648 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4649 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4650 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4652 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4653 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4654 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4655 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4656 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4657 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4659 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4660 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4661 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4662 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4663 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4664 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4666 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4667 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4668 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4669 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4671 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4672 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4673 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4674 number of arguments.
4676 @findex current_function_pops_args
4677 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4678 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4679 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4680 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4681 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4686 @findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4687 A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4688 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4689 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4690 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4691 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4692 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4693 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4694 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4695 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4698 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4699 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4700 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4701 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4702 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4706 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4707 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4708 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4709 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4712 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4713 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4714 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4715 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4718 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4719 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4720 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4721 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4722 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4725 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4726 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4727 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4728 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4731 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4732 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4733 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4734 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4737 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4738 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4739 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4740 on entry to an exception edge.
4743 @defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4744 Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4745 instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4746 definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4747 representing the number of delay slots there.
4750 @defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4751 A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4752 slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4754 The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4755 being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4756 eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4757 of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4758 If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4759 may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4760 (at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4763 @findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4764 @findex final_scan_insn
4765 The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4766 list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4767 @code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4768 delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4769 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4770 outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4771 @code{final_scan_insn}.
4773 You need not define this macro if you did not define
4774 @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4777 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4778 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4779 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4780 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4781 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4784 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4785 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4786 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4787 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4788 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4789 all other incoming arguments.
4791 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4792 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4793 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4796 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4799 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4800 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4801 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4802 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4804 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4805 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4806 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4807 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4809 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4810 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4811 some targets, but probably not.
4813 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4814 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4815 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4816 not support varargs.
4819 @hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4820 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4821 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4822 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4823 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4828 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4829 @cindex profiling, code generation
4831 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4833 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4834 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4835 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4838 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4839 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4840 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4841 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4843 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4844 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4845 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4846 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4849 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4850 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4851 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4852 not support profiling.
4855 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4856 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4857 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4858 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4859 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4860 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4863 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4864 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4865 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4869 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4872 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4873 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4874 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4875 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4877 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4878 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4879 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4880 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4881 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4882 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4885 @hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4886 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4887 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4888 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4889 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4890 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4891 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4894 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4895 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4896 @cindex stack smashing protection
4898 @hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4899 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4900 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4901 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4902 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4903 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4905 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4906 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4909 @hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4910 This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4911 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4912 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4914 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4915 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4916 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4919 @hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4922 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4923 @cindex varargs implementation
4925 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4926 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4927 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4928 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4929 conditionals to include it.
4931 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4932 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4933 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4934 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4935 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4936 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4938 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4939 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4942 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4943 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4944 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4945 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4946 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4948 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4949 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4950 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4951 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4953 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4954 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4955 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4956 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4957 to use them for its own purposes.
4958 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4962 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4963 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4964 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4965 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4966 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4967 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4968 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4969 of the current function.
4972 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4973 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4974 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4975 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4976 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4977 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4979 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4980 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4981 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4983 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4984 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4987 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4989 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4990 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4991 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
4992 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
4993 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
4994 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4997 @hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4998 This target hook offers an alternative to using
4999 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5000 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5001 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5002 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5003 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5004 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5006 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5007 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5008 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5009 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5011 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5012 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5013 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5014 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5015 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5018 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5019 compile time without knowing their data types,
5020 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5021 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5024 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5025 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5026 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5027 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5028 not generate any instructions in this case.
5031 @hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5032 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5033 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5035 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
5036 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5037 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5038 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5039 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5040 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5041 except the last are treated as named.
5043 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5046 @hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5047 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5048 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5049 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5050 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5051 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5052 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5056 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5057 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5058 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5060 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5061 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5062 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5063 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5066 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5067 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5068 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5069 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5070 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5071 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5072 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5075 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5076 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5077 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5078 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5079 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5080 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5083 @hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5084 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5085 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5086 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5087 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5089 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5090 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5091 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5092 to generate it on the spot.
5095 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5096 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5097 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5100 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5101 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5104 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5105 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5107 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5108 is used for aligning trampolines.
5111 @hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5112 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5113 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5114 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5115 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5118 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5119 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5120 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5121 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5122 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5123 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5125 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5126 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5127 initializing the trampoline proper.
5130 @hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5131 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5132 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5133 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5134 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5135 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5136 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5137 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5140 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5141 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5142 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5143 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5145 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5146 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5147 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5148 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5149 latter makes initialization faster.
5151 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5152 the following macro.
5154 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5155 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5156 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5157 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5158 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5161 The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
5162 before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
5163 the following macro.
5165 @defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5166 Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
5167 code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
5168 file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
5169 named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
5170 emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
5171 @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT} hook.
5174 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5175 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5176 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5177 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5178 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5180 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5181 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5182 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5183 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5184 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5186 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5187 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5188 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5189 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5190 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5191 special assembler code.
5195 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5196 @cindex library subroutine names
5197 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5199 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5200 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5202 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5203 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5204 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5205 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5206 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5209 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5210 @findex init_one_libfunc
5211 @hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5212 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5213 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5214 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5215 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5218 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5221 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5222 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5223 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5224 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5227 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5228 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5229 don't need to define this macro.
5232 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5233 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5234 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5235 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5236 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5237 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5238 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5239 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5242 @cindex US Software GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5243 @cindex floating point emulation library, US Software GOFAST
5244 @cindex GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5245 @findex gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs
5246 @defmac US_SOFTWARE_GOFAST
5247 Define this macro if your system C library uses the US Software GOFAST
5248 library to provide floating point emulation.
5250 In addition to defining this macro, your architecture must set
5251 @code{TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS} to @code{gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs}, or
5252 else call that function from its version of that hook. It is defined
5253 in @file{config/gofast.h}, which must be included by your
5254 architecture's @file{@var{cpu}.c} file. See @file{sparc/sparc.c} for
5257 If this macro is defined, the
5258 @code{TARGET_FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL} target hook must return
5259 false for @code{SFmode} and @code{DFmode} comparisons.
5262 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5265 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5266 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5267 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5268 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5271 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5272 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5273 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5274 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5275 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5278 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5279 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5280 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5281 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5282 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5283 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5286 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5287 @defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5288 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5289 @code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5290 default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5291 functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5292 systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5295 @cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5296 @defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5297 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5298 and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5299 default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5301 void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5302 void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5303 void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5307 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5308 Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5309 the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5310 involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5311 at once to the method-lookup library function.
5313 The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5314 to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5317 @node Addressing Modes
5318 @section Addressing Modes
5319 @cindex addressing modes
5321 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5322 This is about addressing modes.
5324 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5325 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5326 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5327 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5328 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5329 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5332 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5333 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5334 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5335 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5336 the size of the memory operand.
5339 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5340 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5341 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5342 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5345 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5346 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5347 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5348 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5349 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5350 constant addresses are supported.
5353 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5354 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5355 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5356 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5357 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5358 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5361 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5362 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5363 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5364 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5368 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5369 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5370 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5372 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5373 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5374 desired by the caller.
5376 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5377 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5378 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5379 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5380 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5381 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5382 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5383 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5385 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5386 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5387 register is required.
5389 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5390 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5391 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5392 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5393 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5395 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5396 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5397 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5398 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5399 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5401 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5402 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5403 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5404 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5405 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5406 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5407 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5410 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5411 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5412 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5416 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5420 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5421 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5423 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5424 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5425 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5426 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5427 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5429 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5430 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5433 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5434 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5435 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5436 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5437 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5438 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5439 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5440 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5441 @code{'m'} constraint.
5444 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5445 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5446 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5447 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5448 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5450 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5451 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5453 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5454 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5457 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5458 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5459 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5462 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5463 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5464 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5467 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5468 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5469 should return the new @var{x}.
5471 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5472 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5473 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5474 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5475 strategy can generate better code.
5478 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5479 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5480 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5481 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5482 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5483 performance reasons.
5485 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5486 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5487 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5488 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5489 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5490 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5491 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5494 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5495 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5496 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5497 of reload internals.
5499 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5500 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5501 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5504 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5505 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5506 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5508 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5509 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5510 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5511 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5514 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5515 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5516 the address has become legitimate.
5519 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5520 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5521 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5522 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5523 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5524 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5527 @hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5528 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5529 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5530 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5533 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5534 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5535 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5536 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5538 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5540 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5543 @defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5544 A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5545 @var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5546 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5547 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5550 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5551 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5552 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5553 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5555 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5557 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5558 @code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5561 @defmac LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5562 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5563 an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5564 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5565 @samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5566 anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5569 @hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5570 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5571 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5572 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5573 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5574 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5575 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5576 into their original form.
5579 @hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5580 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5581 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. The default version of
5582 this hook returns false.
5584 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5585 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5586 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5587 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5588 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5591 @hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5592 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5593 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5596 The default version returns false for all constants.
5599 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
5600 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5601 the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5602 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5603 when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5604 @var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5605 of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5609 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5610 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5611 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5612 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5613 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5615 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5616 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5617 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5618 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5619 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5620 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5621 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5622 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5623 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5624 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5625 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5627 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5628 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5629 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5630 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5631 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5633 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5634 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5635 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5638 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5639 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5640 widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5642 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5643 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5644 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5645 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5646 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5649 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5650 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5651 widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5653 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5654 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5655 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5656 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5657 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5660 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5661 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5662 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5663 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5666 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5667 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5670 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM
5671 Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5674 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK
5675 Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5678 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5679 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5680 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5681 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5682 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5683 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5685 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5686 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5687 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5690 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5691 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5692 vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5693 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5694 The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5695 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5696 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5699 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5700 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5701 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5702 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5703 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5704 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5707 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5708 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5709 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5710 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5711 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5714 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5715 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5716 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5717 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5718 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5721 @node Anchored Addresses
5722 @section Anchored Addresses
5723 @cindex anchored addresses
5724 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5726 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5727 For example, if we have:
5731 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5734 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5735 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5736 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5737 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5743 register int *xr = &x;
5744 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5748 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5749 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5751 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5752 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5753 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5754 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5756 @hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5757 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5758 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5759 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5760 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5763 @hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5764 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5765 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5769 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5770 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5771 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5772 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5773 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5775 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5776 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5777 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5778 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5781 @hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5782 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5783 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5784 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5786 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5787 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5788 or target-specific sections.
5791 @node Condition Code
5792 @section Condition Code Status
5793 @cindex condition code status
5795 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5796 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5798 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5799 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5800 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5801 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5802 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5803 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5806 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5807 the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5808 insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5809 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5810 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5811 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5812 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5813 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5815 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5816 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5817 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5818 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5819 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5820 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5821 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5823 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5824 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5825 interested in most macros in this section.
5828 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5829 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5830 * Cond. Exec. Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5833 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5834 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5838 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5839 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5840 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5841 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5842 currently based, and several standard flags.
5844 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5845 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5846 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5848 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5849 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5850 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5852 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5855 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5856 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5857 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5858 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5859 define this macro to initialize it.
5861 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5864 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5865 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5866 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5867 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5868 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5871 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5873 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5874 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5875 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5876 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5877 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5878 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5879 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5880 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5881 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5882 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5883 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5884 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5885 condition code value.
5887 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5888 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5889 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5890 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5891 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5892 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5893 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5895 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5896 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5897 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5898 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5901 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5902 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5906 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5907 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5908 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5909 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5910 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5911 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5912 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5913 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5914 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5915 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5916 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5918 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5919 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5920 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5921 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5922 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5923 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5924 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5928 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5930 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5931 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5938 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5939 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5942 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5943 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5944 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5945 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5946 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5947 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5950 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5951 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5954 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5955 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5958 @defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5959 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5960 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5961 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5962 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5964 On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5965 required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5966 and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5967 comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5968 @var{op1} as required.
5970 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5971 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5974 You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5978 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5979 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5980 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5981 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5982 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5984 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5985 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5986 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5987 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5990 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5994 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5995 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5996 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5997 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5998 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5999 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6000 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6004 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6005 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6006 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6010 @hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
6011 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6012 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6013 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6014 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6015 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6016 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6017 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6018 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6019 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6020 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6022 The default version of this hook returns false.
6025 @hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
6026 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6027 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6028 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6029 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6030 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6031 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6033 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6034 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6035 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6038 @node Cond. Exec. Macros
6039 @subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6040 @findex conditional execution
6043 There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6044 supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6045 represent conditional branches.
6047 @defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6048 A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6049 @var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6050 versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6051 predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6052 that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6053 If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6056 #define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6057 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6062 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6063 @cindex costs of instructions
6064 @cindex relative costs
6065 @cindex speed of instructions
6067 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6068 on the target machine.
6070 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6071 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6072 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6073 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6074 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6077 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6078 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6079 registers if they are not general registers.
6081 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6082 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6083 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6084 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6085 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6086 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6088 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6089 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6092 @hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6093 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6094 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6095 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6096 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6099 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6100 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6101 registers if they are not general registers.
6103 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6104 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6105 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6106 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6107 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6108 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6110 The default version of this function returns 2.
6113 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6114 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6115 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6116 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6117 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6118 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6119 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6121 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6122 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6123 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6124 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6125 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6126 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6128 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6129 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6130 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6131 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6132 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6133 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6134 are the same as to this macro.
6136 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6137 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6140 @hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
6141 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6142 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6143 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6144 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6145 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6146 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6148 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6149 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6150 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6151 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6152 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6153 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6155 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6156 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6157 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6158 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6159 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6160 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6161 are the same as to this target hook.
6164 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6165 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is the
6166 default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter @var{speed_p}
6167 is true when the branch in question should be optimized for speed. When
6168 it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should be returning value optimal for code size
6169 rather then performance considerations. @var{predictable_p} is true for well
6170 predictable branches. On many architectures the @code{BRANCH_COST} can be
6174 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6175 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6178 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6179 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6180 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6181 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6182 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6183 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6185 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6186 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6187 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6188 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6189 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6190 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6193 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6194 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6195 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6196 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6199 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6200 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6201 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6202 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6203 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6205 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6206 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6207 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6210 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6211 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6212 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6213 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6214 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6216 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6217 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6218 the number of such sequences.
6220 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6221 optimized for speed rather than size.
6223 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6226 @defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6227 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6228 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6229 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6230 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6233 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6234 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6235 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6238 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6239 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6240 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6241 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6242 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6244 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6245 optimized for speed rather than size.
6247 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6250 @defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6251 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6252 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6253 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6254 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6257 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6258 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6259 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6260 a block set insn or a library call.
6261 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6262 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6264 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6265 optimized for speed rather than size.
6267 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6270 @defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6271 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6272 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6273 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6274 storing values other than constant zero.
6275 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6276 than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6279 @defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6280 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6281 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6282 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6283 called with a constant source string.
6284 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6285 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6288 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6289 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6290 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6291 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6294 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6295 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6296 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6297 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6300 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6301 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6302 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6303 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6306 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6307 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6308 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6309 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6312 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6313 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6314 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6315 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6318 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6319 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6320 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6321 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6324 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6325 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6326 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6327 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6330 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6331 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6332 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6333 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6336 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6337 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6338 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6341 @defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6342 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6343 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6344 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6347 @hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6348 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6350 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6351 available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6352 in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6353 expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6354 @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6356 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6357 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6360 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6361 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6362 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6363 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6364 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6366 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6367 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6368 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6370 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6371 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6374 @hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6375 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6376 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6377 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6379 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6380 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6381 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6382 all addresses will have equal costs.
6384 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6385 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6386 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6388 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6389 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6390 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6391 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6392 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6393 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6394 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6395 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6397 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6399 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6400 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6401 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6402 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6403 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6404 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6405 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6406 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6410 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6412 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6413 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6414 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6415 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6417 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6418 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6419 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6420 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6421 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6422 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6423 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6424 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6425 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6426 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6429 @hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6430 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6431 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6432 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6433 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6434 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6435 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6436 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6437 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6438 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6439 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6443 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6444 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6445 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6446 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6447 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6448 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6449 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6450 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6451 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6452 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6453 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6454 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6455 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6458 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6459 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6460 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6461 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6462 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6463 scheduling priorities of insns.
6466 @hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6467 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6468 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6469 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6470 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6471 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6472 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6473 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6474 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6475 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6476 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6477 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6478 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6479 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6480 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6483 @hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6484 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6485 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6486 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6487 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6488 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6489 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6490 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6491 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6494 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6495 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6496 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6497 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6498 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6499 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6500 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6504 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6505 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6506 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6507 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6508 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6509 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6510 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6511 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6514 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6515 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6516 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6517 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6518 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6519 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6520 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6523 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6524 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6525 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6526 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6527 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6530 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6531 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6532 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6533 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6536 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6537 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6538 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6539 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6540 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6541 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6542 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6543 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6546 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6547 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6550 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6551 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6552 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6553 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6556 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6557 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6558 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6561 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6562 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6563 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6564 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6565 state on a single insn is not enough.
6568 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6569 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6570 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6571 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6572 state on a single insn is not enough.
6575 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6576 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6577 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6578 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6579 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6580 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6581 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6582 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6583 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6584 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6585 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6587 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6588 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6589 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6590 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6591 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6592 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6593 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6594 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6595 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6597 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6598 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6599 schedules to choose the best one.
6601 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6604 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6606 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6607 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6608 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6611 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6614 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
6615 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6619 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
6620 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6623 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
6624 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6628 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
6629 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6630 round of multipass scheduling.
6633 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
6634 This hook initilizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6637 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
6638 This hook finilizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6641 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
6642 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6643 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6644 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6645 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6646 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6647 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6648 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6649 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6650 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6651 and the current processor cycle.
6654 @hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6655 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6656 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6657 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6658 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6659 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6660 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6661 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6662 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6663 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6664 and @code{false} otherwise.
6666 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6667 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6668 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6669 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6670 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6671 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6672 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6675 @hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6676 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6677 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6678 per instruction data structures.
6681 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6682 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6685 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6686 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6687 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6688 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6691 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6692 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6695 @hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6696 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6699 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6700 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6703 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6704 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6705 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6706 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6707 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6708 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6709 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6710 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6711 the generated speculative pattern.
6714 @hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6715 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6716 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6717 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6720 @hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6721 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6722 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6723 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6724 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6725 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6726 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6727 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6728 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6731 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6732 This hook is used as a workaround for
6733 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6734 called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6735 discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6736 being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6737 @var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6738 For non-speculative instructions,
6739 the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6740 the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6744 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6745 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6747 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6748 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6751 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6752 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6753 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6754 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6755 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6756 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6757 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6760 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6761 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6762 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6765 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6766 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6767 in its second parameter.
6771 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6772 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6773 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6775 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6776 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6777 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6778 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6779 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6782 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6783 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6784 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6785 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6786 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6787 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6788 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6790 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6791 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6792 to be string literals.
6794 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6795 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6796 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6797 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6799 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6800 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6801 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6802 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6803 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6804 reuse @code{text_section}.
6806 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6807 if the target does not provide them.
6809 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6810 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6811 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6812 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6815 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6816 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6817 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6818 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6821 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6822 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6823 executed functions in the program.
6826 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6827 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6828 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6829 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6832 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6833 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6834 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6835 initialized, writable small data.
6838 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6839 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6840 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6844 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6845 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6846 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6847 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
6848 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
6849 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6850 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6854 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6855 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6856 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6857 uninitialized, writable small data.
6860 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6861 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6862 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6863 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6866 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6867 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6868 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6869 default is @code{'T'}.
6872 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6873 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6874 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6875 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6876 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6877 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6880 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6881 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6882 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6883 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6884 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6885 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6888 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6889 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6890 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6891 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6892 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6893 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6896 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6897 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6898 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6899 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6900 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6901 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6904 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6905 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6906 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6907 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6908 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6909 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6910 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6911 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6912 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6913 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6916 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6917 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6918 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6919 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6920 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6921 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6922 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6923 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6924 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6925 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6926 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6929 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6930 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6931 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6932 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6933 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6936 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6937 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6938 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6939 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6940 readonly data section is used.
6942 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6945 @hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6946 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6947 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6948 of its own that you need to create.
6950 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6951 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6955 @hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6956 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6957 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6958 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6959 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6961 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6962 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6963 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6964 in read-only sections even in executables.
6967 @hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6968 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6969 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6970 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6971 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6972 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6973 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6975 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6976 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6978 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6981 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6982 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6983 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6985 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6986 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6987 it is unlikely to be called.
6990 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
6991 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6992 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6993 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
6994 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
6996 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
6997 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
6998 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
6999 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7002 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
7003 Return the readonly data section associated with
7004 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7005 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7006 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7007 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7011 @hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
7012 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7013 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7014 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7015 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7018 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7019 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7020 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7023 @hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7024 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7025 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7026 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7027 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7028 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7029 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7030 returns the @var{id} provided.
7033 @hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7034 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7035 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7036 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7038 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7039 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7040 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7041 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7042 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7044 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7045 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7046 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7047 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7048 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7051 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7052 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7053 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7054 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7055 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7056 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7058 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7059 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7060 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7061 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7062 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7063 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7065 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7066 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7067 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7068 before overriding it.
7071 @hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7072 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7073 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7077 @hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7078 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7079 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7082 @hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7083 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7084 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7087 @hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7089 @hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7090 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7091 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7092 or executable image).
7094 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7095 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7096 currently supported object file formats.
7099 @hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7100 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7101 The default value is false.
7106 @section Position Independent Code
7107 @cindex position independent code
7110 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7111 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7112 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7113 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7114 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7115 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7116 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7117 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7119 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7120 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7122 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7123 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7124 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7125 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7126 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7127 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7128 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7129 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7130 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7133 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7134 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7135 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7136 the default is zero. Do not define
7137 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7140 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7141 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7142 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7143 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7144 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7145 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7146 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7147 position independent code.
7150 @node Assembler Format
7151 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7153 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7154 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7158 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7159 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7160 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7161 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7162 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7163 and termination routines.
7164 * Macros for Initialization::
7165 Specific macros that control the handling of
7166 initialization and termination routines.
7167 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7168 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7169 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7170 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7173 @node File Framework
7174 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7175 @cindex assembler format
7176 @cindex output of assembler code
7178 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7179 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7181 @findex default_file_start
7182 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7183 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7184 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7185 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7186 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7187 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7188 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7191 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7192 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7193 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7194 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7195 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7196 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7197 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7198 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7200 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7201 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7202 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7205 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7206 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7207 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7208 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7209 this to be done. The default is false.
7212 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7213 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7214 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7217 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7218 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7219 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7220 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7221 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7222 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7226 @hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7227 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7228 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7232 @hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7233 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7234 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7238 @hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7239 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7240 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7241 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7242 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7246 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7247 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7248 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7249 the end of the line.
7253 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7254 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7255 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7256 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7257 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7261 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7262 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7263 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7264 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7267 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7268 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7269 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7270 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7272 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7273 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7276 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7278 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7279 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7280 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7281 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7282 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7283 of the filename using this macro.
7286 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7287 A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7288 @samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7289 macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7292 @hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7293 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7294 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7295 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7296 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7297 this section is associated.
7300 @hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7301 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7304 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7305 @hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7306 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7307 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7308 This is true on most ELF targets.
7311 @hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7312 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7313 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7314 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7315 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7317 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7318 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7319 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7320 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7323 @hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7324 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7325 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7326 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7327 It can take the following values:
7330 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7331 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7333 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7334 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7335 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7336 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7337 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7338 various different individual optimization passes.
7340 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7341 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7342 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7343 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7344 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7345 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7346 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7347 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7348 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7351 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7352 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7354 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7355 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7358 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7359 supported in the future.
7361 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7362 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7363 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7364 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7365 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7369 @hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7370 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7371 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7377 @subsection Output of Data
7380 @hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7381 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7382 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7383 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7384 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7385 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7386 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7387 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7388 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7389 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7390 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7391 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7392 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7393 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7395 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7396 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7397 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7400 @hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7401 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7402 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7403 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7404 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7405 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7406 split the object into smaller parts.
7408 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7409 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7410 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7413 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7414 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7415 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7416 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7417 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7419 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7420 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7421 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7425 @defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7426 A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7427 @code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7428 @var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7429 allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7431 If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7432 @code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7433 prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7434 @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7437 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7438 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7439 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7440 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7441 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7443 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7444 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7445 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7448 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7449 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7450 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7451 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7454 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7455 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7456 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7457 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7458 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7459 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7460 pool before the function.
7463 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7464 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7465 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7466 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7467 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7468 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7469 immediately after this call.
7471 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7475 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7476 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7477 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7478 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7480 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7481 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7482 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7483 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7484 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7487 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7488 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7489 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7490 Here is how to do this:
7493 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7496 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7497 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7498 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7500 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7503 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7504 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7505 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7506 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7507 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7508 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7510 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7514 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7515 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7516 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7517 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7518 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7520 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7521 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7524 @hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7525 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7526 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7527 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7530 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7531 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7533 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7534 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7535 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7536 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7537 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7538 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7539 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7540 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7541 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7542 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7543 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7544 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7545 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7546 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7547 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7548 on the host machine.
7550 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7551 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7555 @node Uninitialized Data
7556 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7558 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7559 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7561 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7562 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7563 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7564 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7565 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7566 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7567 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7568 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7569 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7570 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7571 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7572 an ordinary undefined external.
7574 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7575 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7576 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7578 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7579 common global variables are output.
7582 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7583 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7584 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7585 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7586 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7587 as the number of bits.
7590 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7591 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7592 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7593 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7594 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7595 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7596 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7599 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7600 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7601 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7602 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7603 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7605 Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
7606 defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7607 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7608 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7609 the name, and a newline.
7611 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define either
7612 this macro or its aligned counterpart, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS}.
7613 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7614 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7615 You do not need to do both.
7617 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7618 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7619 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7620 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7621 common in order to save space in the object file.
7624 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7625 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
7626 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7627 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
7628 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7629 as the number of bits.
7631 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7632 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
7635 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7636 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7637 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7638 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7639 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7641 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7642 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7643 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7645 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7646 static variables are output.
7649 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7650 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7651 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7652 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7653 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7654 as the number of bits.
7657 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7658 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7659 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7660 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7661 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7662 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7663 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7667 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7669 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7670 This is about outputting labels.
7672 @findex assemble_name
7673 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7674 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7675 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7676 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7677 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7678 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7679 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7682 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7683 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7684 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7686 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7687 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7688 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7689 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7691 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7692 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7695 @findex assemble_name_raw
7696 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7697 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7698 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7699 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7700 that it is more efficient.
7704 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7705 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7706 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7707 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7709 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7710 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7711 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7712 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7716 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7717 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7718 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7719 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7720 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7724 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7725 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7726 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7727 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7730 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7731 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7732 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7733 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7734 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7735 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7739 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7740 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7741 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7742 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7744 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7745 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7746 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7747 types at all, do not define this macro.
7750 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7751 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7752 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7753 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7754 the default is not to define this macro.
7756 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7757 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7758 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7759 types at all, do not define this macro.
7762 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7763 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7764 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7765 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7766 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7767 you should not count on this.
7769 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7770 definition of this macro is provided.
7773 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7774 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7775 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7776 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7777 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7778 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7779 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7781 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7782 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7784 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7788 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7789 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7790 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7791 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7792 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7793 representing the function.
7795 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7797 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7801 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7802 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7803 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7804 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7805 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7806 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7808 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7809 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7811 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7812 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7815 @hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
7816 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7817 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7818 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7819 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7820 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7821 will be an internal label.
7823 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7824 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7826 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7829 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7830 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7831 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7832 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7834 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7838 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7839 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7840 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7841 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7842 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7843 something about the size of the object.
7845 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7848 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7849 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7852 @hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7853 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7854 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7855 that is, available for reference from other files.
7857 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7858 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7861 @hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7862 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7863 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7864 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7866 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7869 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7870 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7871 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7872 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7873 no other definition is available. Use the expression
7874 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7875 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7876 for making that name weak, and a newline.
7878 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7879 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7883 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7884 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7885 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7886 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7887 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7888 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7889 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7890 to make @var{name} weak.
7893 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7894 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7895 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7896 declaration of @code{name}.
7899 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
7900 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7901 supports weak symbols.
7903 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7904 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
7905 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7908 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7909 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7911 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7912 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7913 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7914 flag such as @option{-melf}.
7917 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7918 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7919 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7920 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7921 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7922 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7923 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7926 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7927 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7930 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7931 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7932 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7933 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7934 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7935 be emitted as one-only.
7938 @hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7939 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7940 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7941 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7944 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7945 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7946 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7947 The default is @code{0}.
7949 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7950 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7951 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7952 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7953 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7954 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7955 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7957 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7958 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7959 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7963 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7964 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7965 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7966 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7967 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7970 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7971 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7974 @hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7975 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7976 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7977 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7980 @hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
7981 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7982 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
7983 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
7986 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7987 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7988 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7989 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7990 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7991 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
7994 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
7995 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
7996 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
7997 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
7998 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
7999 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8002 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8003 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8004 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8005 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8006 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8007 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8008 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8012 @hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
8013 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8014 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8016 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8017 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8018 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8020 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8021 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8022 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8023 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8024 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8026 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8029 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8030 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8031 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8032 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8033 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8034 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8035 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8038 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8042 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8043 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8044 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8046 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8047 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8048 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8050 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8051 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8052 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8053 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8054 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8055 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8056 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8059 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8060 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8061 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8062 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8063 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8065 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8066 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8067 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8068 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8069 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8070 internal static variables in different scopes.
8072 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8073 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8074 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8075 between the name and the number will suffice.
8077 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8078 which is correct for most systems.
8081 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8082 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8083 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8086 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8087 correct for most systems.
8090 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8091 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8092 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8093 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8094 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8095 the tree nodes are available.
8098 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8099 correct for most systems.
8102 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8103 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8104 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8105 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8106 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8107 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8108 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8111 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8112 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8113 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8114 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8115 an undefined weak symbol.
8117 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8118 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8121 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8122 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8123 Objective-C methods.
8125 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8126 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8127 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8130 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8131 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8132 systems define other ways of computing names.
8134 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8135 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8136 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8137 50 characters extra.
8139 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8140 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8141 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8142 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8144 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8145 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8148 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8149 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8150 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8151 Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8152 linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8155 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8156 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8157 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8158 unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8159 whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8162 @node Initialization
8163 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8164 @cindex initialization routines
8165 @cindex termination routines
8166 @cindex constructors, output of
8167 @cindex destructors, output of
8169 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8170 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8171 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8172 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8173 @code{main} is called.
8175 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8176 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8179 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8180 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8181 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8182 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8184 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8185 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8186 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8188 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8189 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8190 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8191 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8192 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8194 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8195 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8196 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8197 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8198 pointer containing zero.
8200 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8201 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8202 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8203 list; destructors in forward order.
8205 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8206 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8207 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8208 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8209 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8210 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8211 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8212 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8214 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8215 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8216 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8217 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8218 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8220 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8221 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8222 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8223 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8224 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8227 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8230 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8231 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8232 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8233 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8234 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8236 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8237 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8238 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8239 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8240 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8241 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8243 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8246 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8247 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8248 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8249 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8250 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8251 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8253 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8254 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8255 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8256 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8257 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8258 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8259 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8260 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8261 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8262 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8263 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8264 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8265 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8266 the initialization process.
8268 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8269 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8270 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8271 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8272 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8273 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8274 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8275 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8276 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8277 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8278 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8281 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8282 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8285 @node Macros for Initialization
8286 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8288 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8289 and termination functions:
8291 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8292 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8293 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8294 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8295 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8296 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8297 run the initialization functions.
8300 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8301 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8302 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8303 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8304 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8307 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8308 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8309 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8312 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8313 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8314 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8317 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8318 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8319 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8320 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8321 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8322 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8324 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8325 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8326 exception tables embedded in the code.
8329 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8330 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8331 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8332 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8333 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8334 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8337 @defmac INVOKE__main
8338 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8339 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8340 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8341 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8344 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8345 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8346 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8347 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8348 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8351 @hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8352 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8353 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8354 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8357 @hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8358 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8359 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8361 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8362 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8363 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8364 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8366 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8367 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8368 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8372 @hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8373 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8374 functions rather than initialization functions.
8377 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8378 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8380 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8381 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8382 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8384 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8385 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8387 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8388 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8389 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8390 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8392 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8393 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8396 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8397 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8398 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8401 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8402 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8403 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8404 termination functions in shared libraries:
8408 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8409 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
8412 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8413 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8414 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8415 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8416 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8417 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8418 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8421 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8422 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8423 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8424 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8425 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8426 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8429 @node Instruction Output
8430 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8432 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8433 This describes assembler instruction output.
8435 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8436 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8437 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8438 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8441 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8442 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8443 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8444 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8445 to registers using alternate names.
8448 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8449 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8450 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8452 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8453 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8454 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8455 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8456 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8457 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8458 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8459 so that it will not be output twice.
8461 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8462 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8463 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8464 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8465 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8467 @findex recog_data.operand
8468 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8469 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8471 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8475 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8476 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8477 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8478 they will be output differently.
8480 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8481 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8482 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8483 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8484 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8485 by changing the contents of the vector.
8487 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8488 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8489 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8490 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8491 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8492 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8494 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8497 @hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8498 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8499 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8502 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8503 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8504 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8505 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8506 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8507 by checking the contents of the vector.
8510 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8511 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8512 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8515 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8516 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8517 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8518 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8519 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8520 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8521 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8524 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8525 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8526 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8527 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8529 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8530 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8531 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8535 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8536 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8537 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8538 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8539 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8543 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8544 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8545 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8546 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8548 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8549 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8550 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8551 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8552 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8556 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8557 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8558 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8559 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8560 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8561 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8564 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8565 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8566 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8569 @findex final_sequence
8570 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8571 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8572 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8573 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8574 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8578 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8579 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8580 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8581 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8582 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8583 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8584 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8585 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8586 files can define these macros differently.
8589 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8590 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8591 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8592 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8593 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8594 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8595 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8596 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8597 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8598 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8599 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8602 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8603 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8604 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8605 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8608 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8610 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8613 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8614 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8615 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8616 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8617 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8618 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8619 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8621 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8622 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8623 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8625 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8626 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8627 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8628 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8629 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8630 opcodes or operand order.
8633 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8634 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8635 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8636 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8640 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8641 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8642 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8643 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8647 @node Dispatch Tables
8648 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8650 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8651 This concerns dispatch tables.
8653 @cindex dispatch table
8654 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8655 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8656 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8657 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8658 definitions of these labels are output using
8659 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8660 way here. For example,
8663 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8664 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8667 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8668 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8669 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8670 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8671 mode and flags can be read.
8674 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8675 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8676 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8678 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8679 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8680 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8681 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8685 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8689 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8690 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8691 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8692 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8693 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8694 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8696 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8699 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8700 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8703 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8704 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8705 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8706 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8707 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8708 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8709 of the preceding label.
8711 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8715 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8716 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8717 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8718 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8719 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8720 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8721 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8722 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8724 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8727 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8728 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8729 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8730 to be broken up according to function.
8732 The default is that no label is emitted.
8735 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8737 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8738 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8739 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8740 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8743 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8745 @node Exception Region Output
8746 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8748 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8750 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8753 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8754 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8755 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8756 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8757 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8759 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8760 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8763 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8764 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8765 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8766 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8767 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8769 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8773 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8774 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8775 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8776 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8777 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8780 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8781 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8782 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8785 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8786 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8787 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8788 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8789 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8790 or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8793 @hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8794 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8795 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8796 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8797 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8798 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8799 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8801 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8802 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8803 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8805 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8806 not depend on anything except command-line switches. In particular, the
8807 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8808 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8809 depending on this setting.
8811 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8812 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8813 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}.
8816 @hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8817 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8818 tables even when exceptions are not used.
8821 @defmac MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS
8822 This macro need only be defined if @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} is
8823 runtime-variable. In that case, @file{except.h} cannot correctly
8824 determine the corresponding definition of @code{MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS},
8825 so the target must provide it directly.
8828 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8829 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8830 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8831 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8834 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8835 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8836 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8837 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8838 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8839 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8840 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8843 @hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8844 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8845 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8846 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8850 @hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8851 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8852 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8853 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8854 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8855 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8856 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8859 @hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8860 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8861 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8862 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8863 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8864 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8865 @var{address} is the address of the table.
8868 @hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8869 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8870 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8871 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8872 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8875 @hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8876 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8877 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8878 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8879 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8882 @node Alignment Output
8883 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8885 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8886 This describes commands for alignment.
8888 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8889 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8890 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8892 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8893 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8896 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8897 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8898 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8899 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8902 @hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8903 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8904 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8905 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8908 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8909 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8912 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8913 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8917 @hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8918 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8919 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8920 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8923 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8924 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8925 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8927 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8928 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8931 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8932 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8933 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8934 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8937 @hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8938 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8939 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8943 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8944 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8945 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8946 the maximum of the specified values is used.
8948 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8949 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8950 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8951 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8954 @hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8955 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8956 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8960 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8961 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8962 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8963 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8964 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8967 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8968 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8969 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
8970 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8971 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8975 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8976 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8977 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8978 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
8981 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8982 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8983 for padding, if necessary.
8986 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
8987 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8988 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8989 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
8990 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
8991 a C expression of type @code{int}.
8995 @node Debugging Info
8996 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
8998 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8999 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9002 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9003 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9004 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9005 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9006 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9007 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9011 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9013 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9014 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9016 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9017 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9018 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9019 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9020 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9021 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9022 compiler and another for DBX@.
9024 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9025 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9026 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9027 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9028 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9030 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9031 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9032 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9035 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9036 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9037 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9038 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9039 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9040 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9041 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9042 @option{-g} options is used.
9045 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9046 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9047 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9051 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9052 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9053 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9054 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9055 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9056 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9057 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9059 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9060 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9061 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9062 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9063 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9065 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9066 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9067 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9071 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9073 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9074 These are specific options for DBX output.
9076 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9077 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9078 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9081 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9082 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9083 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9086 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9087 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9088 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9089 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9090 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9091 if there is any occasion to.
9094 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9095 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9096 in the text section.
9099 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9100 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9101 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9102 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9103 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9106 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9107 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9108 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9109 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9110 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9114 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9115 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9116 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9117 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9118 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9121 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9122 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9123 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9124 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9125 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9128 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9129 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9130 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9131 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9132 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9133 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9134 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9135 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9138 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9139 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9140 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9141 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9142 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9143 if backslash is correct for your system.
9146 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9147 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9148 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9152 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9153 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9154 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9157 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9158 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9159 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9160 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9163 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9164 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9165 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9166 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9169 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9170 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9171 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9172 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9175 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9176 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9177 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9178 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9182 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9183 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9184 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9185 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9186 an absolute address.
9189 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9190 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9191 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9192 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9195 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9196 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9197 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9198 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9199 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9200 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9201 number for a type number.
9205 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9207 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9208 These are hooks for DBX format.
9210 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9211 Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9212 information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9213 argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9214 @code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9217 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9218 Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9221 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9222 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9223 output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9226 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9227 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9228 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9229 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9230 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9231 unique labels in the assembly output.
9233 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9234 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9237 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9238 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9239 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9240 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9241 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9244 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9245 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9246 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9247 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9250 @node File Names and DBX
9251 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9253 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9254 This describes file names in DBX format.
9256 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9257 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9258 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9259 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9260 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9262 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9263 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9265 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9266 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9267 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9268 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9271 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9272 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9273 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9274 the beginning of the file.
9277 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9278 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9279 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9280 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9281 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9284 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9285 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9286 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9287 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9289 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9290 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9293 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9294 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9295 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9296 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9297 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9302 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9304 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9305 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9307 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9308 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9309 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9312 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9313 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9314 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9316 @hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9317 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9318 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9319 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9322 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9323 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9324 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9325 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9326 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9329 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9330 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9331 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9332 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9333 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9334 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9337 @hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9338 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9339 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9340 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9341 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9343 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9344 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9346 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9347 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9350 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9351 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9352 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9353 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9356 @hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9358 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9359 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9360 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9363 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9364 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9365 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9366 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9369 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9370 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9371 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9372 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9375 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9376 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9377 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9380 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9381 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9382 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9383 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9384 is referenced by a function.
9387 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9388 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9389 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9392 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9393 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9394 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9395 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9396 not define them yourself.
9400 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9401 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9402 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9403 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9407 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9408 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9409 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9410 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9414 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9415 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9416 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9417 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9420 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9421 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9422 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9423 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9428 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9430 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9431 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9433 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9434 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9435 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9436 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9437 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9438 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9439 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9442 @node Floating Point
9443 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9444 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9445 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9447 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9448 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9449 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9450 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9451 doing the compilation.
9453 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9454 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9455 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9456 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9457 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9458 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9459 target floating point formats are identical.
9461 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9462 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9463 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9464 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9466 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9467 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9468 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9469 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9473 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9474 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9475 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9476 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9477 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9480 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9481 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9484 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9485 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9488 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9489 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9490 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9493 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9494 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9495 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9496 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9497 defined by the C language for both.
9500 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9501 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9504 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9505 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9508 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9509 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9512 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9513 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9514 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9517 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9518 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9519 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9521 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9522 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9523 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9524 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9527 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9528 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9531 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9532 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9535 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9536 Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9537 return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9538 appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9539 precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9542 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9543 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9544 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9545 integral, it is truncated.
9548 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9549 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9550 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9551 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9554 @node Mode Switching
9555 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9556 @cindex mode switching
9557 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9559 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9560 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9561 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9563 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9564 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9565 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9566 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9567 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9568 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9569 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9571 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9572 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9573 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9574 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9575 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9576 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9577 @code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9581 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9582 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9583 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9584 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9585 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9586 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9587 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9589 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9590 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9591 switch is needed / supplied.
9594 @defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9595 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9596 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9597 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9598 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9599 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9602 @defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9603 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9604 mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9605 different from the incoming mode).
9608 @defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9609 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9610 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9611 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9612 is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9615 @defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9616 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9617 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9618 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9619 is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9622 @defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9623 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
9624 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9625 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9626 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9627 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9628 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9631 @defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9632 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9633 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9634 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9637 @node Target Attributes
9638 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9639 @cindex target attributes
9640 @cindex machine attributes
9641 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9643 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9644 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9645 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9647 @hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9648 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9649 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9650 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9651 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9655 @hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9656 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9657 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9658 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9659 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9660 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9663 @hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9664 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9665 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9666 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9667 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9668 supposed always to be compatible.
9671 @hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9672 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9673 the newly defined @var{type}.
9676 @hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9677 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9678 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9679 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9680 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9681 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9685 @hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9686 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9687 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9688 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9689 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9690 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9691 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9692 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9694 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9695 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9696 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9697 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9698 will then define a function called
9699 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9700 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9701 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9702 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9703 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9704 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9707 @hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9709 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9710 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9711 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9712 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9713 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9714 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9715 on this implementation detail.
9718 @hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9719 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9720 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9721 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9722 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9723 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9724 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9725 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9726 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9727 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9731 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9733 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9734 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9735 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9736 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9739 @hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9740 This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9741 it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9742 options for the current function that might be different than the
9743 options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9744 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9746 The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9747 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9748 @var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9751 @hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9752 This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9753 in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9755 @xref{Option file format}.
9758 @hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9759 This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9760 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9761 function specific options.
9764 @hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9765 This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9766 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9767 function specific options.
9770 @hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
9771 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9772 set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9773 input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
9774 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9777 @hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9778 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9779 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9780 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9781 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9783 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9784 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9786 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9787 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9788 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9791 @hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9792 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9793 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9794 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9795 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9799 @section Emulating TLS
9800 @cindex Emulated TLS
9802 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9803 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9804 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9805 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9806 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9809 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9810 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9811 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9812 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9814 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9815 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9816 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9817 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9820 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9821 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9822 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9823 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9824 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9825 registration function to be used.
9828 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9829 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9830 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9834 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9835 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9836 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9840 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9841 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9842 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9845 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9846 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9847 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9850 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9851 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9852 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9853 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9854 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9855 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9858 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9859 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9860 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9861 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9862 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9865 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9866 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9867 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9868 single objects. The default is false.
9871 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9872 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9873 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9876 @node MIPS Coprocessors
9877 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9878 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9880 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9881 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9882 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9883 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9886 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9892 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9893 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9894 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9896 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9897 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9898 later in the function.
9900 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9901 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9902 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9904 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9905 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9907 @defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9908 A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9909 alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9911 @{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9917 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9918 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9920 @hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9921 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9922 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9923 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9926 @hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9927 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9928 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9929 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9930 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9932 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9933 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9934 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9935 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9937 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9938 suitable for most targets.
9941 @hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9942 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9943 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9944 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9945 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9946 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9950 @section C++ ABI parameters
9951 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
9953 @hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9954 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9955 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9956 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9959 @hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9960 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9961 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9962 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9965 @hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
9966 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9967 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9968 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9969 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
9970 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
9973 @hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
9974 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
9975 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
9978 @hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
9979 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
9980 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
9981 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
9982 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
9983 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
9984 backend's targeted operating system.
9987 @hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
9988 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
9989 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
9993 @hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
9994 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
9995 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
9996 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
9997 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
9998 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
9999 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10000 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10003 @hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
10005 @hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
10006 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10007 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10008 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10009 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10010 unit will not be COMDAT.
10013 @hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10014 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10015 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10016 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10019 @hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10020 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10021 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10022 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10025 @hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10026 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10027 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10028 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10029 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10030 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10033 @hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10035 @node Named Address Spaces
10036 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10037 @cindex named address spaces
10039 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10040 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10041 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10042 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10043 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10044 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10045 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10046 @code{const} type attributes.
10048 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10049 pointers to the generic address space.
10051 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10052 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10053 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10054 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10055 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10056 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10057 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10060 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10061 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10064 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10065 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10066 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10067 named address space #1:
10069 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10070 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10073 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10074 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10075 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10076 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10077 generic address space only.
10080 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10081 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10082 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10083 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10084 generic address space only.
10087 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10088 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10089 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10090 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10091 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10092 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10093 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10094 target hooks for the given address space.
10097 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10098 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10099 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10100 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10101 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10102 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10103 explicit named address space support.
10106 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10107 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10108 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10109 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10110 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10113 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10114 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10115 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10116 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10117 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10118 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10119 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10122 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10123 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10124 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10125 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10126 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10127 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10128 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10132 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10133 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10135 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10136 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10138 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10139 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10140 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10141 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10142 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10143 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10144 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10147 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10148 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10149 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10150 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10151 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10152 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10153 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10156 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10157 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10158 elements of a jump-table should have.
10161 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10162 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10163 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10164 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10165 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10166 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10167 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10168 flags can be updated.
10171 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10172 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10173 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10174 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10175 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10179 @hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10180 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10181 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10182 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10183 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10186 @defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10187 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10188 statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10189 advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10190 of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10191 targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10192 @code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10193 @code{false} otherwise.
10196 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10197 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10198 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10199 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10202 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10203 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10204 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10205 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10206 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10207 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10208 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10209 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10211 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10212 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10213 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10214 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10215 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10217 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10218 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10219 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10220 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10221 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10223 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10224 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10225 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10226 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10229 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10230 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10234 @defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10235 Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10236 point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10240 @hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10241 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10242 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10243 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10244 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10245 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10246 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10250 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10251 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10254 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10255 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10256 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10257 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10258 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10262 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10263 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10264 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10265 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10266 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10267 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10268 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10269 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10270 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10271 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10272 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10274 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10275 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10276 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10278 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10279 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10280 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10281 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10282 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10284 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10287 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10288 @hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10289 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10290 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10291 @xref{shift patterns}.
10293 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10294 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10295 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10296 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10297 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10298 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10300 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10301 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10302 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10304 The default implementation of this function returns
10305 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10306 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10307 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10308 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10312 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10313 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10314 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10315 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10316 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10318 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10320 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10321 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10322 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10323 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10324 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10325 such cases may improve things.
10328 @hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10329 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10330 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10331 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10332 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10333 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10334 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10335 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10336 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10337 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10338 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10340 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10341 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10342 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10343 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10345 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10346 describe two related properties. If you define
10347 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10348 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10351 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10352 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10356 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10357 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10358 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10359 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10360 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10361 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10363 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10364 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10365 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10366 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10367 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10368 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10369 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10370 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10373 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10374 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10375 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10376 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10377 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10378 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10379 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10383 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10387 can be converted to
10390 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10394 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10395 tested into the sign bit.
10397 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10398 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10399 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10400 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10401 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10402 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10404 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10405 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10406 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10411 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10412 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10413 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10414 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10415 combine the normalization with other operations.
10418 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10419 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10423 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10424 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10428 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10431 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10432 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10433 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10434 those cases, e.g., one matching
10437 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10440 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10441 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10442 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10443 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10444 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10445 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10446 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
10447 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10449 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10450 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10451 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10454 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10455 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10456 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10457 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10458 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10462 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10463 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10464 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10465 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10466 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10467 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10468 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10469 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10470 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10474 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10475 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10476 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10477 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10478 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10479 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10480 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10481 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10482 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10483 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10486 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10487 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10489 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10490 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10491 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10492 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10494 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10495 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10496 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10497 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10502 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10503 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10504 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10505 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10506 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10508 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10509 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10510 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10514 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10515 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10516 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10517 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10518 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10519 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10520 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10523 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10524 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10525 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10526 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10527 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10528 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10530 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10531 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10532 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10535 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10536 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10537 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10538 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10539 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10544 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10545 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10546 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10547 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10548 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10549 setup required for the pragmas.
10551 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10552 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10553 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10555 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10556 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10558 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10559 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10560 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10563 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10564 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10566 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10567 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10568 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10572 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10575 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10576 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10577 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10578 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10579 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10580 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10581 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10582 arguments of pragmas registered with
10583 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10584 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10586 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10587 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10588 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10589 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10590 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10591 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10592 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10593 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10594 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10595 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10596 how to build this object file.
10601 @defmac HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
10602 Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
10603 pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
10604 [=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
10606 The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
10607 within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
10608 @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A pack value of zero resets
10609 the behavior to the default.
10611 A subtlety for Microsoft Visual C/C++ style bit-field packing
10612 (e.g.@: -mms-bitfields) for targets that support it:
10613 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
10614 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
10615 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
10616 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
10617 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
10618 size is allocated).
10620 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
10621 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
10622 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
10623 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
10624 may affect its placement.
10626 The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
10627 @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined. If enabled it allows the creation
10628 of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
10633 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
10634 Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
10635 style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push[,@var{n}])} and @samp{#pragma
10636 pack(pop)}. The @samp{pack(push,[@var{n}])} pragma specifies the maximum
10637 alignment (in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as
10638 the @samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A
10639 pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default. Successive
10640 invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
10641 that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
10645 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10646 Define this macro, as well as
10647 @code{HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA}, if macros should be expanded in the
10648 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10651 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10653 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10654 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10655 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10656 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10657 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10660 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10661 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10662 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10663 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10664 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10667 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10668 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10669 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10670 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10671 @samp{.} is used instead.
10674 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10675 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10676 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10677 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10678 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10681 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10682 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10683 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10684 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10685 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10686 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10687 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10688 you should define this macro.
10690 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10693 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10694 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10695 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10696 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10697 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10698 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10699 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10700 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10701 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10702 slot of @var{insn}.
10704 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10707 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10708 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10709 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10710 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10711 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10712 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10714 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10717 @hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10718 This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10719 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10720 It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10721 clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10722 corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10723 clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10724 @code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10725 for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10728 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10729 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10730 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10731 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10732 separate math library.
10734 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10737 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10738 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10739 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10741 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10745 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10746 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10747 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10748 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10749 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10750 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10751 for cross-profiling.
10754 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10756 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10757 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10758 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10759 1 if it does use cc0.
10762 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10763 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10764 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10765 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10766 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10767 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10768 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10769 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10772 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10773 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10774 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10775 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10776 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10779 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10780 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10781 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10782 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10783 about the currently processed blocks.
10786 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10787 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10788 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10789 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10790 to by @var{ce_info}.
10793 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10794 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10795 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10796 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10797 to by @var{ce_info}.
10800 @defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10801 A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10802 structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10805 @defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10806 If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10807 added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10808 by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10811 @hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10812 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10813 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10814 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10816 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10817 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10818 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10819 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10821 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10822 definition is null.
10825 @hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10826 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10827 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10830 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10831 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10832 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10833 instructions or prefetch instructions).
10835 To create a built-in function, call the function
10836 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10837 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10838 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
10839 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10840 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10843 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10844 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10845 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10846 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10847 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10848 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10849 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10850 @code{error_mark_node}.
10853 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10855 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10856 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10857 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10858 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10859 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10860 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10861 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10865 @hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
10866 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10867 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10868 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10869 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10870 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10871 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10872 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10873 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10874 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10877 @hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
10878 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10879 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10880 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10881 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10882 The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10883 call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10886 @hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10888 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10889 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10890 could not be applied.
10892 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10893 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10894 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10895 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10896 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10899 @defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10901 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10902 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10903 @var{branch2} is possible.
10905 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10906 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10907 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10910 @hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10911 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10912 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10913 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10914 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10917 @hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10919 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10920 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10921 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10922 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10923 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10924 that had its initial value copied by using
10925 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10926 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10927 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10928 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10930 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10931 it might decide to use another register anyways.
10932 You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10933 that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10934 register in question will not be clobbered.
10935 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10939 @hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10940 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10941 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10942 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10943 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10944 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10948 @hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
10949 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10950 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10951 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10952 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10953 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10954 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10955 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10956 and is returning to processing at the top level.
10957 The default hook function does nothing.
10959 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10960 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10961 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10962 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10963 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10964 outside of any function scope.
10967 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10968 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10969 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10970 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10973 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10974 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10975 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10976 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10980 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10981 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10982 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10983 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10984 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10988 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10989 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10990 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10991 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10992 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10993 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10994 defined as this expression:
10997 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10999 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11004 @hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
11005 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11006 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11007 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11008 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11012 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11014 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11019 @hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
11020 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11021 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11022 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11023 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11024 to inter-block scheduling.
11027 @hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
11028 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11030 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11031 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11032 that all target registers in the class returned by
11033 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11034 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11035 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11036 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11037 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11038 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11041 @hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
11042 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11043 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11044 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11047 @hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
11048 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11049 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11050 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11051 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11052 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11053 number of memory accesses.
11056 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11057 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11058 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11059 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11060 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11061 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11062 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11063 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11066 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11067 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11068 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11069 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11070 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11073 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11074 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11075 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11076 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11077 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11078 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11081 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11082 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11083 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11084 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11085 that are different from @option{-I}.
11088 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11089 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11090 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11091 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11092 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11093 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11096 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11097 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11098 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11099 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11102 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11103 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11104 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11107 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11108 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11109 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11110 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11111 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11114 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11115 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11116 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11119 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11120 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11121 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11122 and scanf formatter settings.
11125 @hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11126 If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11127 guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11128 main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11129 important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11130 many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11131 ``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11132 and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11135 @hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11136 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11137 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11138 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11141 @hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11142 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11143 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11144 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11147 @hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11148 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11149 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11150 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11151 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11154 @hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11155 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11156 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11157 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11161 @hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11162 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11163 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11164 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11165 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11168 @hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11169 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11170 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11171 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11172 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11175 @hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
11176 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11177 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11178 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11179 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11180 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11181 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11184 @hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
11185 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11186 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11187 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11188 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11190 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11193 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11194 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11195 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11196 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11200 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11201 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11204 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11205 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11206 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11207 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11208 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11211 @hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11212 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11216 @hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11217 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11218 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11219 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11223 @hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11224 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11225 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11226 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11227 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11228 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11229 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11230 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11231 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11234 @hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11235 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11236 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11237 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11238 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11239 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11240 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11241 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11242 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11243 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11244 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11245 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11246 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11247 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11248 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11249 is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr